xref: /linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 1553a1c48281243359a9529a10ddb551f3b967ab)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2024 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218  *	bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220  *	was changed.
221  */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
224 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
225 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
226 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
227 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
228 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP		= BIT(5),
229 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING	= BIT(6),
230 };
231 
232 /**
233  * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234  * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235  * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236  *	(otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237  */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 	struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242 
243 /**
244  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245  *
246  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248  *
249  * @def: the channel definition
250  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251  * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252  *	for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
254  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
255  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
256  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
257  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
258  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
259  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
260  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
261  */
262 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
263 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
264 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
265 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
266 
267 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
268 
269 	bool radar_enabled;
270 
271 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
272 };
273 
274 /**
275  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
276  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
277  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
278  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
279  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
280  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
281  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
282  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
283  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
284  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
285  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
286  *      for changes/removal.)
287  */
288 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
289 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
290 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
291 };
292 
293 /**
294  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
295  *
296  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
297  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
298  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
299  * done.
300  *
301  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
302  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
303  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
304  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
305  */
306 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
307 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
308 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
309 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
310 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
311 };
312 
313 /**
314  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
315  *
316  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
317  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
318  *
319  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
320  *	also implies a change in the AID.
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
322  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
324  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
326  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
328  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
329  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
330  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
332  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
333  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
334  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
336  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
337  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
339  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
342  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
344  *	changed
345  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
346  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
347  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
348  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
349  *	context had been assigned.
350  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
351  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
352  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
353  *	keep alive) changed.
354  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
355  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
356  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
357  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
358  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
359  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
360  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
361  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
362  *	status changed.
363  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
364  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: TID to link mapping was changed
365  */
366 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
367 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
368 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
369 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
370 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
379 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
380 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
381 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
382 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
383 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
384 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
385 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
386 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
387 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
388 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
389 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
390 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
391 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
392 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
393 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
394 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
395 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
396 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
397 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
398 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
399 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
400 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM		= BIT_ULL(34),
401 
402 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
403 };
404 
405 /*
406  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
407  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
408  * filtering will be disabled.
409  */
410 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
411 
412 /**
413  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
414  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
415  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
416  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
417  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
418  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
419  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
420  */
421 enum ieee80211_event_type {
422 	RSSI_EVENT,
423 	MLME_EVENT,
424 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
425 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
426 };
427 
428 /**
429  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
430  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
431  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
432  */
433 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
434 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
435 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
436 };
437 
438 /**
439  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
440  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
441  */
442 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
443 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
444 };
445 
446 /**
447  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
448  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
449  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
450  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
451  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
452  */
453 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
454 	AUTH_EVENT,
455 	ASSOC_EVENT,
456 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
457 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
458 };
459 
460 /**
461  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
462  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
463  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
464  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
465  */
466 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
467 	MLME_SUCCESS,
468 	MLME_DENIED,
469 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
470 };
471 
472 /**
473  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
474  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
475  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
476  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
477  */
478 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
479 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
480 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
481 	u16 reason;
482 };
483 
484 /**
485  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
486  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
487  * @tid: the tid
488  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
489  */
490 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
491 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
492 	u16 tid;
493 	u16 ssn;
494 };
495 
496 /**
497  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
498  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
499  * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
500  * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
501  * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
502  * @u:union holding the fields above
503  */
504 struct ieee80211_event {
505 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
506 	union {
507 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
508 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
509 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
510 	} u;
511 };
512 
513 /**
514  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
515  *
516  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
517  *
518  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
519  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
520  */
521 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
522 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
523 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
524 };
525 
526 /**
527  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
528  *
529  * @lci: LCI subelement content
530  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
531  * @lci_len: LCI data length
532  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
533  */
534 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
535 	const u8 *lci;
536 	const u8 *civicloc;
537 	size_t lci_len;
538 	size_t civicloc_len;
539 };
540 
541 /**
542  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
543  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
544  *
545  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
546  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
547  */
548 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
549 	u32 min_interval;
550 	u32 max_interval;
551 };
552 
553 /**
554  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
555  *
556  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
557  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
558  *
559  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
560  * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
561  *	when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
562  *	necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
563  *	responses.
564  * @addr: (link) address used locally
565  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
566  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
567  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
568  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
569  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
570  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
571  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
572  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
573  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
574  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
575  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
576  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
577  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
578  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
579  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
580  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
581  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
582  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
583  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
584  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
585  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
586  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
587  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
588  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
589  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
590  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
591  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
592  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
593  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
594  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
595  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
596  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
597  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
598  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
599  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
600  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
601  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
602  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
603  *	the current band.
604  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
605  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
606  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
607  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
608  * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
609  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
610  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
611  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
612  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
613  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
614  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
615  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
616  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
617  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
618  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
619  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
620  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
621  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
622  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
623  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
624  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
625  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
626  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
627  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
628  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
629  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
630  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
631  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
632  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
633  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
634  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
635  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
636  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
637  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
638  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
639  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
640  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
641  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
642  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
643  *	station.
644  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
645  *	responder functionality.
646  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
647  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
648  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
649  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
650  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
651  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
652  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
653  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
654  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
655  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
656  *	connected to (STA)
657  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
658  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
659  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
660  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
661  *	interval.
662  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
663  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
664  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
665  * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
666  * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
667  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
668  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
669  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
670  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
671  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
672  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
673  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
674  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
675  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
676  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
677  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
678  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
679  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
680  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
681  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
682  *	beamformer
683  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
684  *	beamformee
685  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
686  *	beamformer
687  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
688  *	beamformee
689  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
690  *	beamformer
691  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
692  *	beamformee
693  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
694  *	beamformer
695  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
696  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
697  *	bandwidth
698  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
699  *	beamformer
700  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
701  *	beamformee
702  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
703  *	beamformer
704  */
705 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
706 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
707 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
708 
709 	const u8 *bssid;
710 	unsigned int link_id;
711 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
712 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
713 	bool uora_exists;
714 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
715 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
716 	bool he_support;
717 	bool twt_requester;
718 	bool twt_responder;
719 	bool twt_protected;
720 	bool twt_broadcast;
721 	/* erp related data */
722 	bool use_cts_prot;
723 	bool use_short_preamble;
724 	bool use_short_slot;
725 	bool enable_beacon;
726 	u8 dtim_period;
727 	u16 beacon_int;
728 	u16 assoc_capability;
729 	u64 sync_tsf;
730 	u32 sync_device_ts;
731 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
732 	u32 basic_rates;
733 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
734 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
735 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
736 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
737 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
738 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
739 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
740 	struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
741 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
742 	bool qos;
743 	bool hidden_ssid;
744 	int txpower;
745 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
746 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
747 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
748 	u16 max_idle_period;
749 	bool protected_keep_alive;
750 	bool ftm_responder;
751 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
752 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
753 	bool nontransmitted;
754 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
755 	u8 bssid_index;
756 	u8 bssid_indicator;
757 	bool ema_ap;
758 	u8 profile_periodicity;
759 	struct {
760 		u32 params;
761 		u16 nss_set;
762 	} he_oper;
763 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
764 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
765 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
766 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
767 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
768 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
769 	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
770 	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
771 	u8 pwr_reduction;
772 	bool eht_support;
773 
774 	bool csa_active;
775 
776 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
777 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
778 
779 	bool color_change_active;
780 	u8 color_change_color;
781 
782 	bool ht_ldpc;
783 	bool vht_ldpc;
784 	bool he_ldpc;
785 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
786 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
787 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
788 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
789 	bool he_su_beamformer;
790 	bool he_su_beamformee;
791 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
792 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
793 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
794 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
795 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
796 };
797 
798 /**
799  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
800  *
801  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
802  *
803  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
804  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
805  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
806  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
807  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
808  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
809  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
810  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
811  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
812  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
813  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
814  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
815  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
816  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
817  *	station
818  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
819  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
820  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
821  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
822  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
823  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
824  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
825  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
826  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
827  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
828  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
829  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
830  *	hardware queue.
831  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
832  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
833  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
834  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
835  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
836  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
837  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
838  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
839  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
840  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
841  *	off-channel operation.
842  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
843  *	(header conversion)
844  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
845  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
846  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
847  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
848  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
849  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
850  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
851  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
852  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
853  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
854  *	queue gets full.
855  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
856  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
857  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
858  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
859  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
860  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
861  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
862  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
863  *	status to user space)
864  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
865  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
866  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
867  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
868  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
869  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
870  *	handled properly by the device.
871  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
872  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
873  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
874  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
875  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
876  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
877  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
878  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
879  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
880  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
881  *	PS-Poll responses.
882  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
883  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
884  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
885  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
886  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
887  *	monitor injection).
888  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
889  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
890  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
891  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
892  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
893  *
894  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
895  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
896  */
897 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
898 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
899 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
900 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
901 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
902 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
903 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
904 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
905 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
906 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
907 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
908 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
909 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
910 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
911 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
912 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
913 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
914 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
915 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
916 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
917 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
918 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
919 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
920 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
921 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
922 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
923 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
924 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
925 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
926 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
927 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
928 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
929 };
930 
931 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
932 
933 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
934 
935 /**
936  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
937  *
938  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
939  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
940  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
941  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
942  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
943  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
944  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
945  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
946  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
947  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
948  *	it can be sent out.
949  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
950  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
951  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
952  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
953  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
954  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
955  *	for sequence number assignment
956  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
957  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
958  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
959  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
960  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
961  *	it's intended for an MLD.
962  *
963  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
964  */
965 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
966 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
967 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
968 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
969 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
970 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
971 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
972 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
973 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
974 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
975 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
976 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
977 };
978 
979 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
980 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
981 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
982 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
983 
984 /**
985  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
986  *
987  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
988  *
989  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
990  */
991 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
992 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
993 };
994 
995 /*
996  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
997  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
998  */
999 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
1000 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
1001 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
1002 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
1003 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
1004 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
1005 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
1006 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1007 
1008 /**
1009  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1010  *	Rate Control algorithm.
1011  *
1012  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1013  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1014  *
1015  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1016  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1017  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1018  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1019  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1020  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1021  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1022  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1023  *	Greenfield mode.
1024  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1025  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1026  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1027  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1028  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1029  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1030  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1031  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1032  */
1033 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1034 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1035 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1036 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1037 
1038 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1039 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1040 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1041 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1042 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1043 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1044 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1045 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1046 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1047 };
1048 
1049 
1050 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1051 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1052 
1053 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1054 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1055 
1056 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1057 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1058 
1059 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1060 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1061 
1062 /**
1063  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1064  *
1065  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1066  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1067  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1068  *
1069  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1070  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1071  *
1072  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1073  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1074  *
1075  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1076  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1077  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1078  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1079  * information::
1080  *
1081  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1082  *
1083  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1084  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1085  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1086  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1087  * information should then contain::
1088  *
1089  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1090  *
1091  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1092  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1093  */
1094 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1095 	s8 idx;
1096 	u16 count:5,
1097 	    flags:11;
1098 } __packed;
1099 
1100 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1101 
1102 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1103 {
1104 	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1105 }
1106 
1107 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1108 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1109 {
1110 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1111 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1112 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1113 }
1114 
1115 static inline u8
1116 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1117 {
1118 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1119 }
1120 
1121 static inline u8
1122 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1123 {
1124 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1125 }
1126 
1127 /**
1128  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1129  *
1130  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1131  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1132  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1133  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1134  *
1135  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1136  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1137  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1138  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1139  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1140  * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1141  *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1142  * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1143  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1144  * @control: union part for control data
1145  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1146  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1147  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1148  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1149  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1150  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1151  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1152  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1153  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1154  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1155  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1156  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1157  * @pad: padding
1158  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1159  * @status: union part for status data
1160  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1161  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1162  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1163  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1164  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1165  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1166  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1167  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1168  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1169  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1170  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1171  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1172  */
1173 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1174 	/* common information */
1175 	u32 flags;
1176 	u32 band:3,
1177 	    status_data_idr:1,
1178 	    status_data:13,
1179 	    hw_queue:4,
1180 	    tx_time_est:10;
1181 	/* 1 free bit */
1182 
1183 	union {
1184 		struct {
1185 			union {
1186 				/* rate control */
1187 				struct {
1188 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1189 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1190 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1191 					u8 use_rts:1;
1192 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1193 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1194 					u8 skip_table:1;
1195 
1196 					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1197 					u8 antennas:2;
1198 
1199 					/* 14 bits free */
1200 				};
1201 				/* only needed before rate control */
1202 				unsigned long jiffies;
1203 			};
1204 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1205 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1206 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1207 			u32 flags;
1208 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1209 		} control;
1210 		struct {
1211 			u64 cookie;
1212 		} ack;
1213 		struct {
1214 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1215 			s32 ack_signal;
1216 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1217 			u8 ampdu_len;
1218 			u8 antenna;
1219 			u8 pad;
1220 			u16 tx_time;
1221 			u8 flags;
1222 			u8 pad2;
1223 			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1224 		} status;
1225 		struct {
1226 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1227 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1228 			u8 pad[4];
1229 
1230 			void *rate_driver_data[
1231 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1232 		};
1233 		void *driver_data[
1234 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1235 	};
1236 };
1237 
1238 static inline u16
1239 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1240 {
1241 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1242 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1243 	 */
1244 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1245 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1246 }
1247 
1248 static inline u16
1249 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1250 {
1251 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1252 }
1253 
1254 /***
1255  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1256  *
1257  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1258  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1259  *
1260  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1261  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1262  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1263  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1264  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1265  */
1266 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1267 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1268 	u8 try_count;
1269 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1270 };
1271 
1272 /**
1273  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1274  *
1275  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1276  * @info: Basic tx status information
1277  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1278  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1279  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1280  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1281  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1282  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1283  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1284  */
1285 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1286 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1287 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1288 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1289 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1290 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1291 	u8 n_rates;
1292 
1293 	struct list_head *free_list;
1294 };
1295 
1296 /**
1297  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1298  *
1299  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1300  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1301  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1302  *
1303  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1304  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1305  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1306  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1307  */
1308 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1309 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1310 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1311 	const u8 *common_ies;
1312 	size_t common_ie_len;
1313 };
1314 
1315 
1316 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1317 {
1318 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1319 }
1320 
1321 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1322 {
1323 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1324 }
1325 
1326 /**
1327  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1328  *
1329  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1330  *
1331  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1332  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1333  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1334  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1335  *
1336  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1337  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1338  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1339  */
1340 static inline void
1341 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1342 {
1343 	int i;
1344 
1345 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1346 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1347 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1348 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1349 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1350 	/* clear the rate counts */
1351 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1352 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1353 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1354 }
1355 
1356 
1357 /**
1358  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1359  *
1360  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1361  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1362  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1363  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1364  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1365  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1366  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1367  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1368  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1369  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1370  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1371  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1372  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1373  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1374  *	de-duplication by itself.
1375  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1376  *	the frame.
1377  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1378  *	the frame.
1379  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1380  *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1381  *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1382  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1383  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1384  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1385  *	merging.
1386  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1387  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1388  *	(including FCS) was received.
1389  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1390  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1391  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1392  *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1393  *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1394  *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1395  *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1396  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1397  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1398  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1399  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1400  *	each A-MPDU
1401  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1402  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1403  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1404  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1405  *	on this subframe
1406  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1407  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1408  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1409  *	done by the hardware
1410  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1411  *	processing it in any regular way.
1412  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1413  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1414  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1415  *	monitor interfaces.
1416  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1417  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1418  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1419  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1420  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1421  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1422  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1423  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1424  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1425  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1426  *	interleaved with other frames.
1427  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1428  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1429  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1430  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1431  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1432  *	in the skb.
1433  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1434  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1435  *	the first subframe.
1436  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1437  *	be done in the hardware.
1438  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1439  *	frame
1440  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1441  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1442  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1443  *
1444  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1445  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1446  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1447  *	 - DATA5_GI
1448  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1449  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1450  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1451  *
1452  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1453  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1454  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1455  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1456  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1457  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1458  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1459  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1460  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1461  *	hardware or driver)
1462  */
1463 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1464 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1465 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1466 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1467 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1468 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1469 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1470 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1471 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1472 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1473 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1474 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1475 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1476 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1477 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1478 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1479 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1480 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1481 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1482 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1483 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1484 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1485 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1486 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1487 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1488 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1489 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1490 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1491 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1492 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1493 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1494 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1495 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1496 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1497 };
1498 
1499 /**
1500  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1501  *
1502  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1503  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1504  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1505  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1506  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1507  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1508  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1509  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1510  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1511  */
1512 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1513 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1514 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1515 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1516 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1517 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1518 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1519 };
1520 
1521 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1522 
1523 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1524 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1525 	RX_ENC_HT,
1526 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1527 	RX_ENC_HE,
1528 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1529 };
1530 
1531 /**
1532  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1533  *
1534  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1535  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1536  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1537  *
1538  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1539  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1540  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1541  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1542  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1543  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1544  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1545  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1546  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1547  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1548  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1549  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1550  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1551  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1552  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1553  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1554  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1555  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1556  *	values were filled.
1557  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1558  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1559  * @antenna: antenna used
1560  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1561  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1562  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1563  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1564  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1565  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1566  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1567  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1568  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1569  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1570  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1571  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1572  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1573  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1574  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1575  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1576  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1577  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1578  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1579  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1580  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1581  *	@link_valid.
1582  */
1583 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1584 	u64 mactime;
1585 	union {
1586 		u64 boottime_ns;
1587 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1588 	};
1589 	u32 device_timestamp;
1590 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1591 	u32 flag;
1592 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1593 	u8 enc_flags;
1594 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1595 	union {
1596 		struct {
1597 			u8 he_ru:3;
1598 			u8 he_gi:2;
1599 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1600 		};
1601 		struct {
1602 			u8 ru:4;
1603 			u8 gi:2;
1604 		} eht;
1605 	};
1606 	u8 rate_idx;
1607 	u8 nss;
1608 	u8 rx_flags;
1609 	u8 band;
1610 	u8 antenna;
1611 	s8 signal;
1612 	u8 chains;
1613 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1614 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1615 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1616 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1617 };
1618 
1619 static inline u32
1620 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1621 {
1622 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1623 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1624 }
1625 
1626 /**
1627  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1628  *
1629  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1630  *
1631  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1632  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1633  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1634  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1635  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1636  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1637  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1638  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1639  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1640  *	for more.
1641  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1642  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1643  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1644  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1645  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1646  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1647  *	operating channel.
1648  */
1649 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1650 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1651 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1652 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1653 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1654 };
1655 
1656 
1657 /**
1658  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1659  *
1660  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1661  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1662  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1663  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1664  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1665  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1666  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1667  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1668  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1669  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1670  */
1671 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1672 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1673 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1674 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1675 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1676 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1677 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1678 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1679 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1680 };
1681 
1682 /**
1683  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1684  *
1685  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1686  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1687  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1688  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1689  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1690  */
1691 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1692 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1693 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1694 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1695 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1696 
1697 	/* keep last */
1698 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1699 };
1700 
1701 /**
1702  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1703  *
1704  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1705  *
1706  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1707  *
1708  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1709  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1710  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1711  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1712  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1713  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1714  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1715  *
1716  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1717  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1718  *
1719  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1720  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1721  *
1722  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1723  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1724  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1725  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1726  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1727  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1728  *
1729  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1730  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1731  *	configured for an HT channel.
1732  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1733  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1734  */
1735 struct ieee80211_conf {
1736 	u32 flags;
1737 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1738 
1739 	u16 listen_interval;
1740 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1741 
1742 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1743 
1744 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1745 	bool radar_enabled;
1746 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1747 };
1748 
1749 /**
1750  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1751  *
1752  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1753  * operation.
1754  *
1755  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1756  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1757  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1758  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1759  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1760  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1761  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1762  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1763  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1764  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1765  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1766  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1767  *	channel, expressed in TU.
1768  * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1769  */
1770 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1771 	u64 timestamp;
1772 	u32 device_timestamp;
1773 	bool block_tx;
1774 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1775 	u8 count;
1776 	u8 link_id;
1777 	u32 delay;
1778 };
1779 
1780 /**
1781  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1782  *
1783  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1784  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1785  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1786  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1787  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1788  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1789  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1790  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1791  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1792  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1793  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1794  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1795  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1796  * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1797  *      enabled for the interface.
1798  * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1799  *	operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1800  *	the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1801  *	handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1802  */
1803 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1804 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1805 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1806 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1807 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1808 	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1809 	IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW	= BIT(5),
1810 };
1811 
1812 
1813 /**
1814  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1815  *
1816  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1817  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1818  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1819  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1820  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1821  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1822  *	mac80211.
1823  */
1824 
1825 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1826 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1827 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1828 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1829 };
1830 
1831 /**
1832  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1833  * @assoc: association status
1834  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1835  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1836  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1837  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1838  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1839  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1840  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1841  *	P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1842  * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1843  *	Figure 9-1001k
1844  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1845  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1846  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1847  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1848  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1849  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1850  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1851  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1852  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1853  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1854  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1855  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1856  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1857  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1858  *	(station mode only)
1859  */
1860 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1861 	/* association related data */
1862 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1863 	bool ibss_creator;
1864 	bool ps;
1865 	u16 aid;
1866 	u16 eml_cap;
1867 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1868 	u16 mld_capa_op;
1869 
1870 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1871 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1872 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1873 	size_t ssid_len;
1874 	bool s1g;
1875 	bool idle;
1876 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1877 };
1878 
1879 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1880 
1881 /**
1882  * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1883  *
1884  * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1885  *	this TID is not included.
1886  * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1887  *	TID is not included.
1888  * @valid: info is valid or not.
1889  */
1890 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1891 	u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1892 	u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1893 	bool valid;
1894 };
1895 
1896 /**
1897  * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1898  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1899  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1900  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1901  */
1902 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1903 	NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1904 	NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1905 	NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1906 };
1907 
1908 /**
1909  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1910  *
1911  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1912  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1913  *
1914  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1915  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1916  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1917  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1918  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1919  *	indexed by link ID
1920  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1921  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1922  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1923  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1924  * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1925  *	Must be a subset of valid_links.
1926  * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1927  *	suspended.
1928  *	0 for non-MLO.
1929  * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1930  *	see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1931  * @addr: address of this interface
1932  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1933  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1934  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1935  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1936  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1937  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1938  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1939  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1940  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1941  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1942  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1943  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1944  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1945  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1946  *	restrictions.
1947  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1948  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1949  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1950  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1951  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1952  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1953  *	interface.
1954  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1955  *	for this interface.
1956  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1957  *	sizeof(void \*).
1958  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1959  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1960  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1961  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1962  */
1963 struct ieee80211_vif {
1964 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1965 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1966 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1967 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1968 	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
1969 	struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
1970 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1971 	bool p2p;
1972 
1973 	u8 cab_queue;
1974 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1975 
1976 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1977 
1978 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1979 	u32 driver_flags;
1980 	u32 offload_flags;
1981 
1982 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1983 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1984 #endif
1985 
1986 	bool probe_req_reg;
1987 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1988 
1989 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1990 
1991 	/* must be last */
1992 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1993 };
1994 
1995 /**
1996  * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
1997  * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
1998  * Return: the usable link bitmap
1999  */
2000 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2001 {
2002 	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2003 }
2004 
2005 /**
2006  * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2007  * @vif: the vif
2008  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2009  */
2010 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2011 {
2012 	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2013 	return vif->valid_links != 0;
2014 }
2015 
2016 /**
2017  * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2018  * @vif: the vif
2019  * @link_id: the link ID to check
2020  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2021  *	the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2022  */
2023 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2024 					     unsigned int link_id)
2025 {
2026 	if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2027 		return link_id == 0;
2028 	return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2029 }
2030 
2031 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
2032 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
2033 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2034 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2035 		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2036 
2037 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2038 {
2039 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2040 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2041 #endif
2042 	return false;
2043 }
2044 
2045 /**
2046  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2047  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2048  *
2049  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2050  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2051  *
2052  * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2053  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2054  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2055  */
2056 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2057 
2058 /**
2059  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2060  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2061  *
2062  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2063  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2064  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2065  */
2066 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2067 
2068 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2069 {
2070 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2071 }
2072 
2073 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
2074 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2075 				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2076 
2077 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
2078 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2079 			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2080 
2081 /**
2082  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2083  *
2084  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2085  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2086  *
2087  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2088  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2089  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2090  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2091  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2092  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2093  *	generation in software.
2094  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2095  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2096  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2097  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2098  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2099  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2100  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2101  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2102  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2103  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2104  *	MIC.
2105  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2106  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2107  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2108  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2109  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2110  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2111  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2112  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2113  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2114  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2115  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2116  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2117  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2118  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2119  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2120  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2121  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2122  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2123  *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2124  *	generation only
2125  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2126  *	(set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2127  */
2128 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2129 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2130 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2131 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2132 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2133 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2134 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2135 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2136 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2137 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2138 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2139 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2140 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU		= BIT(11),
2141 };
2142 
2143 /**
2144  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2145  *
2146  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2147  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2148  *
2149  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2150  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2151  *	encrypted in hardware.
2152  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2153  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2154  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2155  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2156  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2157  * @keylen: key material length
2158  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2159  * 	data block:
2160  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2161  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2162  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2163  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2164  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2165  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2166  */
2167 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2168 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2169 	u32 cipher;
2170 	u8 icv_len;
2171 	u8 iv_len;
2172 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2173 	s8 keyidx;
2174 	u16 flags;
2175 	s8 link_id;
2176 	u8 keylen;
2177 	u8 key[];
2178 };
2179 
2180 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2181 
2182 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2183 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2184 
2185 /**
2186  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2187  *
2188  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2189  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2190  *	reverse order than in packet)
2191  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2192  *	reverse order than in packet)
2193  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2194  *	reverse order than in packet)
2195  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2196  *	reverse order than in packet)
2197  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2198  */
2199 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2200 	union {
2201 		struct {
2202 			u32 iv32;
2203 			u16 iv16;
2204 		} tkip;
2205 		struct {
2206 			u8 pn[6];
2207 		} ccmp;
2208 		struct {
2209 			u8 pn[6];
2210 		} aes_cmac;
2211 		struct {
2212 			u8 pn[6];
2213 		} aes_gmac;
2214 		struct {
2215 			u8 pn[6];
2216 		} gcmp;
2217 		struct {
2218 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2219 			u8 seq_len;
2220 		} hw;
2221 	};
2222 };
2223 
2224 /**
2225  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2226  *
2227  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2228  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2229  *
2230  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2231  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2232  */
2233 enum set_key_cmd {
2234 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2235 };
2236 
2237 /**
2238  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2239  *
2240  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2241  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2242  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2243  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2244  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2245  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2246  */
2247 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2248 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2249 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2250 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2251 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2252 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2253 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2254 };
2255 
2256 /**
2257  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2258  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2259  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2260  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2261  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2262  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2263  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2264  *
2265  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2266  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2267  */
2268 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2269 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2270 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2271 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2272 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2273 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2274 };
2275 
2276 /**
2277  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2278  *
2279  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2280  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2281  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2282  */
2283 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2284 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2285 	struct {
2286 		s8 idx;
2287 		u8 count;
2288 		u8 count_cts;
2289 		u8 count_rts;
2290 		u16 flags;
2291 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2292 };
2293 
2294 /**
2295  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2296  *
2297  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2298  *
2299  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2300  *	to the STA.
2301  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2302  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2303  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2304  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2305  *	per peer TPC.
2306  */
2307 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2308 	s16 power;
2309 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2310 };
2311 
2312 /**
2313  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2314  *
2315  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2316  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2317  *
2318  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2319  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2320  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2321  *
2322  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2323  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2324  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2325  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2326  *
2327  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2328  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2329  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2330  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2331  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2332  */
2333 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2334 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2335 
2336 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2337 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2338 };
2339 
2340 /**
2341  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2342  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2343  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2344  *
2345  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2346  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2347  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2348  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2349  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2350  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2351  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2352  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2353  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2354  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2355  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2356  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2357  * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2358  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2359  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2360  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2361  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2362  *	the station moves to associated state.
2363  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2364  *
2365  */
2366 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2367 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2368 
2369 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2370 	u8 link_id;
2371 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2372 
2373 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2374 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2375 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2376 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2377 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2378 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2379 
2380 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2381 
2382 	u8 rx_nss;
2383 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2384 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2385 };
2386 
2387 /**
2388  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2389  *
2390  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2391  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2392  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2393  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2394  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2395  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2396  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2397  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2398  *
2399  * @addr: MAC address
2400  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2401  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2402  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2403  *	Can be modified by driver.
2404  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2405  *	otherwise always false)
2406  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2407  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2408  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2409  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2410  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2411  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2412  * @rates: rate control selection table
2413  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2414  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2415  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2416  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2417  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2418  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2419  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2420  *	unlimited.
2421  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2422  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2423  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2424  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2425  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2426  *	is used for non-data frames
2427  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2428  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2429  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2430  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2431  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2432  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2433  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2434  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2435  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2436  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2437  *	by the AP.
2438  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2439  * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2440  */
2441 struct ieee80211_sta {
2442 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2443 	u16 aid;
2444 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2445 	bool wme;
2446 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2447 	u8 max_sp;
2448 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2449 	bool tdls;
2450 	bool tdls_initiator;
2451 	bool mfp;
2452 	bool mlo;
2453 	bool spp_amsdu;
2454 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2455 
2456 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2457 
2458 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2459 
2460 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2461 
2462 	u16 valid_links;
2463 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2464 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2465 
2466 	/* must be last */
2467 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2468 };
2469 
2470 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2471 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2472 #else
2473 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2474 {
2475 	return true;
2476 }
2477 #endif
2478 
2479 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2480 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2481 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2482 
2483 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2484 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2485 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2486 
2487 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2488 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2489 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2490 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2491 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2492 
2493 /**
2494  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2495  *
2496  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2497  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2498  *
2499  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2500  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2501  */
2502 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2503 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2504 };
2505 
2506 /**
2507  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2508  *
2509  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2510  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2511  */
2512 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2513 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2514 };
2515 
2516 /**
2517  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2518  *
2519  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2520  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2521  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2522  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2523  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2524  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2525  *
2526  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2527  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2528  */
2529 struct ieee80211_txq {
2530 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2531 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2532 	u8 tid;
2533 	u8 ac;
2534 
2535 	/* must be last */
2536 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2537 };
2538 
2539 /**
2540  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2541  *
2542  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2543  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2544  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2545  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2546  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2547  *
2548  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2549  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2550  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2551  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2552  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2553  *	algorithm.
2554  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2555  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2556  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2557  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2558  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2559  *	CCK frames.
2560  *
2561  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2562  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2563  *	the FCS at the end.
2564  *
2565  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2566  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2567  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2568  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2569  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2570  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2571  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2572  *
2573  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2574  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2575  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2576  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2577  *
2578  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2579  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2580  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2581  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2582  *
2583  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2584  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2585  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2586  *
2587  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2588  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2589  *
2590  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2591  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2592  *
2593  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2594  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2595  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2596  *
2597  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2598  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2599  *
2600  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2601  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2602  *
2603  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2604  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2605  *	the stack.
2606  *
2607  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2608  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2609  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2610  *
2611  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2612  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2613  *	dtim_period).
2614  *
2615  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2616  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2617  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2618  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2619  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2620  *	only in that case.
2621  *
2622  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2623  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2624  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2625  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2626  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2627  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2628  *
2629  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2630  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2631  *	software.
2632  *
2633  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2634  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2635  *	active interfaces.
2636  *
2637  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2638  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2639  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2640  *
2641  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2642  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2643  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2644  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2645  *	supported cipher suites.
2646  *
2647  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2648  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2649  *	for frames.
2650  *
2651  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2652  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2653  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2654  *	control for more details.
2655  *
2656  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2657  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2658  *
2659  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2660  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2661  *	is supported.
2662  *
2663  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2664  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2665  *
2666  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2667  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2668  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2669  *
2670  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2671  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2672  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2673  *	CSA frame.
2674  *
2675  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2676  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2677  *
2678  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2679  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2680  *
2681  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2682  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2683  *
2684  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2685  *	within A-MPDU.
2686  *
2687  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2688  *	for sent beacons.
2689  *
2690  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2691  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2692  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2693  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2694  *
2695  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2696  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2697  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2698  *	timeout.
2699  *
2700  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2701  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2702  *
2703  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2704  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2705  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2706  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2707  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2708  *
2709  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2710  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2711  *
2712  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2713  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2714  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2715  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2716  *
2717  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2718  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2719  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2720  *
2721  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2722  *	TDLS links.
2723  *
2724  * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2725  *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2726  *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2727  *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2728  *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2729  *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2730  *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2731  *
2732  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2733  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2734  *
2735  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2736  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2737  *
2738  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2739  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2740  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2741  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2742  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2743  *
2744  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2745  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2746  *	TXQs to start with.
2747  *
2748  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2749  *	length in tx status information
2750  *
2751  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2752  *
2753  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2754  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2755  *
2756  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2757  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2758  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2759  *
2760  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2761  *	offload
2762  *
2763  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2764  *	offload
2765  *
2766  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2767  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2768  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2769  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2770  *	the stack.
2771  *
2772  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2773  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2774  *
2775  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2776  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2777  *
2778  * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2779  *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2780  *
2781  * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2782  *	no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2783  *	implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2784  *	link is switching.
2785  *
2786  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2787  */
2788 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2789 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2790 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2791 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2792 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2793 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2794 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2795 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2796 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2797 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2798 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2799 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2800 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2801 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2802 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2803 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2804 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2805 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2806 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2807 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2808 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2809 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2810 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2811 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2812 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2813 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2814 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2815 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2816 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2817 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2818 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2819 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2820 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2821 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2822 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2823 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2824 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2825 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2826 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2827 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2828 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2829 	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2830 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2831 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2832 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2833 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2834 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2835 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2836 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2837 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2838 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2839 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2840 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2841 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2842 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2843 	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2844 	IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2845 
2846 	/* keep last, obviously */
2847 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2848 };
2849 
2850 /**
2851  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2852  *
2853  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2854  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2855  *
2856  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2857  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2858  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2859  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2860  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2861  *
2862  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2863  *
2864  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2865  *	along with this structure.
2866  *
2867  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2868  *
2869  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2870  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2871  *
2872  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2873  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2874  *
2875  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2876  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2877  *
2878  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2879  *	that HW supports
2880  *
2881  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2882  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2883  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2884  *
2885  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2886  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2887  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2888  *
2889  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2890  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2891  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2892  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2893  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2894  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2895  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2896  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2897  *
2898  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2899  *	can handle.
2900  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2901  *	the hw can report back.
2902  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2903  *
2904  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2905  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2906  *	aggregation.
2907  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2908  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2909  *	it shouldn't be set.
2910  *
2911  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2912  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2913  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2914  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2915  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2916  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2917  *
2918  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2919  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2920  *
2921  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2922  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2923  *
2924  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2925  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2926  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2927  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2928  *
2929  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2930  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2931  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2932  *
2933  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2934  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2935  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2936  *	device_timestamp.
2937  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2938  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2939  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2940  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2941  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2942  *
2943  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2944  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2945  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2946  *
2947  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2948  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2949  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2950  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2951  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2952  *	neither enabled.
2953  *
2954  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2955  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2956  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2957  *
2958  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2959  *	device.
2960  *
2961  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2962  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2963  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2964  *
2965  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2966  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2967  *
2968  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2969  *
2970  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2971  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2972  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2973  *
2974  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2975  */
2976 struct ieee80211_hw {
2977 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2978 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2979 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2980 	void *priv;
2981 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2982 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2983 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2984 	int vif_data_size;
2985 	int sta_data_size;
2986 	int chanctx_data_size;
2987 	int txq_data_size;
2988 	u16 queues;
2989 	u16 max_listen_interval;
2990 	s8 max_signal;
2991 	u8 max_rates;
2992 	u8 max_report_rates;
2993 	u8 max_rate_tries;
2994 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2995 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2996 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2997 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2998 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2999 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3000 	struct {
3001 		int units_pos;
3002 		s16 accuracy;
3003 	} radiotap_timestamp;
3004 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3005 	u8 uapsd_queues;
3006 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3007 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3008 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3009 	u8 weight_multiplier;
3010 	u32 max_mtu;
3011 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3012 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3013 };
3014 
3015 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3016 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3017 {
3018 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3019 }
3020 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3021 
3022 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3023 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3024 {
3025 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3026 }
3027 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3028 
3029 /**
3030  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3031  *
3032  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3033  * @req: cfg80211 request.
3034  */
3035 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3036 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3037 
3038 	/* Keep last */
3039 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3040 };
3041 
3042 /**
3043  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3044  *
3045  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3046  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3047  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3048  * @status: channel-switch response status
3049  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3050  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3051  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3052  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3053  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3054  */
3055 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3056 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3057 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3058 	u8 action_code;
3059 	u32 status;
3060 	u32 timestamp;
3061 	u16 switch_time;
3062 	u16 switch_timeout;
3063 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3064 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3065 };
3066 
3067 /**
3068  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3069  *
3070  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3071  *
3072  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3073  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3074  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3075  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3076  * is already used internally by mac80211.
3077  *
3078  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3079  */
3080 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3081 
3082 /**
3083  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3084  *
3085  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3086  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3087  */
3088 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3089 {
3090 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3091 }
3092 
3093 /**
3094  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3095  *
3096  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3097  * @addr: the address to set
3098  */
3099 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3100 {
3101 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3102 }
3103 
3104 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3105 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3106 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3107 {
3108 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3109 		return NULL;
3110 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3111 }
3112 
3113 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3114 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3115 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3116 {
3117 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3118 		return NULL;
3119 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3120 }
3121 
3122 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3123 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3124 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3125 {
3126 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3127 		return NULL;
3128 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3129 }
3130 
3131 /**
3132  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3133  * @hw: the hardware
3134  * @skb: the skb
3135  *
3136  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3137  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3138  */
3139 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3140 
3141 /**
3142  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3143  *
3144  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3145  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3146  *
3147  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3148  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3149  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3150  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3151  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3152  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3153  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3154  *
3155  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3156  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3157  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3158  *
3159  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3160  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3161  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3162  * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3163  *
3164  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3165  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3166  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3167  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3168  *
3169  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3170  *
3171  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3172  * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3173  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3174  * based on the receive flags.
3175  *
3176  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3177  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3178  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3179  * keys.
3180  *
3181  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3182  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3183  * handler.
3184  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3185  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3186  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3187  * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3188  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3189  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3190  *
3191  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3192  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3193  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3194  *
3195  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3196  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3197  * requirements:
3198  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3199       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3200    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3201       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3202    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3203       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3204       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3205    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3206    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3207  */
3208 
3209 /**
3210  * DOC: Powersave support
3211  *
3212  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3213  *
3214  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3215  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3216  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3217  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3218  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3219  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3220  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3221  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3222  *
3223  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3224  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3225  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3226  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3227  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3228  *
3229  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3230  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3231  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3232  *
3233  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3234  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3235  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3236  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3237  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3238  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3239  * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3240  *
3241  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3242  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3243  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3244  * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3245  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3246  * periods.
3247  *
3248  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3249  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3250  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3251  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3252  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3253  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3254  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3255  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3256  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3257  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3258  *
3259  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3260  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3261  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3262  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3263  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3264  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3265  *
3266  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3267  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3268  */
3269 
3270 /**
3271  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3272  *
3273  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3274  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3275  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3276  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3277  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3278  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3279  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3280  *
3281  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3282  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3283  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3284  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3285  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3286  *
3287  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3288  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3289  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3290  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3291  *
3292  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3293  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3294  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3295  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3296  *
3297  *  - a list of information element IDs
3298  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3299  *
3300  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3301  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3302  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3303  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3304  * vendor information elements.
3305  *
3306  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3307  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3308  *
3309  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3310  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3311  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3312  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3313  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3314  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3315  *
3316  *
3317  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3318  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3319  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3320  * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3321  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3322  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3323  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3324  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3325  *
3326  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3327  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3328  * signal strength threshold checking.
3329  */
3330 
3331 /**
3332  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3333  *
3334  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3335  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3336  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3337  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3338  *
3339  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3340  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3341  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3342  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3343  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3344  * hardware flags.
3345  *
3346  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3347  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3348  * turned off otherwise.
3349  *
3350  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3351  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3352  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3353  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3354  */
3355 
3356 /**
3357  * DOC: Frame filtering
3358  *
3359  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3360  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3361  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3362  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3363  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3364  *
3365  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3366  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3367  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3368  *
3369  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3370  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3371  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3372  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3373  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3374  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3375  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3376  *
3377  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3378  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3379  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3380  * or dropped.
3381  *
3382  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3383  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3384  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3385  * the flag, but not clear it.
3386  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3387  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3388  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3389  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3390  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3391  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3392  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3393  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3394  */
3395 
3396 /**
3397  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3398  *
3399  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3400  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3401  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3402  *
3403  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3404  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3405  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3406  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3407  * the driver code.
3408  *
3409  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3410  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3411  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3412  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3413  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3414  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3415  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3416  *
3417  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3418  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3419  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3420  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3421  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3422  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3423  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3424  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3425  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3426  * @sta_notify callback.
3427  *
3428  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3429  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3430  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3431  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3432  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3433  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3434  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3435  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3436  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3437  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3438  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3439  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3440  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3441  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3442  *
3443  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3444  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3445  *
3446  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3447  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3448  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3449  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3450  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3451  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3452  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3453  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3454  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3455  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3456  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3457  *
3458  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3459  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3460  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3461  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3462  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3463  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3464  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3465  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3466  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3467  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3468  * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3469  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3470  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3471  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3472  *
3473  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3474  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3475  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3476  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3477  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3478  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3479  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3480  *
3481  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3482  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3483  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3484  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3485  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3486  *
3487  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3488  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3489  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3490  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3491  */
3492 
3493 /**
3494  * DOC: HW queue control
3495  *
3496  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3497  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3498  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3499  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3500  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3501  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3502  *
3503  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3504  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3505  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3506  *
3507  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3508  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3509  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3510  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3511  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3512  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3513  * the hardware queue.
3514  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3515  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3516  *
3517  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3518  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3519  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3520  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3521  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3522  *
3523  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3524  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3525  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3526  * off-channel queue:         9
3527  *
3528  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3529  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3530  *
3531  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3532  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3533  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3534  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3535  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3536  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3537  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3538  *
3539  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3540  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3541  *
3542  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3543  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3544  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3545  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3546  */
3547 
3548 /**
3549  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3550  *
3551  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3552  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3553  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3554  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3555  *
3556  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3557  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3558  *	multicast address.
3559  *
3560  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3561  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3562  *
3563  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3564  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3565  *
3566  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3567  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3568  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3569  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3570  *	honour this flag if possible.
3571  *
3572  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3573  *	station
3574  *
3575  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3576  *
3577  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3578  *
3579  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3580  *
3581  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3582  */
3583 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3584 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3585 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3586 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3587 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3588 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3589 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3590 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3591 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3592 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3593 };
3594 
3595 /**
3596  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3597  *
3598  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3599  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3600  *
3601  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3602  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3603  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3604  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3605  *
3606  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3607  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3608  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3609  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3610  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3611  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3612  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3613  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3614  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3615  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3616  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3617  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3618  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3619  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3620  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3621  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3622  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3623  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3624  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3625  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3626  */
3627 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3628 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3629 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3630 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3631 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3632 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3633 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3634 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3635 };
3636 
3637 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3638 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3639 
3640 /**
3641  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3642  *
3643  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3644  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3645  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3646  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3647  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3648  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3649  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3650  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3651  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3652  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3653  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3654  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3655  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3656  */
3657 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3658 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3659 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3660 	u16 tid;
3661 	u16 ssn;
3662 	u16 buf_size;
3663 	bool amsdu;
3664 	u16 timeout;
3665 };
3666 
3667 /**
3668  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3669  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3670  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3671  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3672  */
3673 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3674 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3675 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3676 };
3677 
3678 /**
3679  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3680  *
3681  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3682  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3683  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3684  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3685  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3686  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3687  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3688  *	the peer.
3689  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3690  *	by the peer
3691  */
3692 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3693 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3694 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3695 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3696 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3697 };
3698 
3699 /**
3700  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3701  *
3702  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3703  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3704  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3705  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3706  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3707  *
3708  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3709  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3710  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3711  */
3712 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3713 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3714 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3715 };
3716 
3717 /**
3718  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3719  *
3720  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3721  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3722  *
3723  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3724  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3725  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3726  *	of wowlan configuration)
3727  */
3728 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3729 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3730 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3731 };
3732 
3733 /**
3734  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3735  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3736  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3737  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3738  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3739  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3740  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3741  * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3742  *	Only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3743  */
3744 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3745 	u16 duration;
3746 	u16 subtype;
3747 	u8 success:1;
3748 	int link_id;
3749 };
3750 
3751 /**
3752  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3753  *
3754  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3755  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3756  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3757  *
3758  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3759  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3760  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3761  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3762  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3763  *	Must be atomic.
3764  *
3765  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3766  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3767  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3768  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3769  *	or zero.
3770  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3771  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3772  *	is added.
3773  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3774  *
3775  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3776  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3777  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3778  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3779  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3780  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3781  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3782  *
3783  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3784  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3785  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3786  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3787  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3788  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3789  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3790  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3791  *	must return 1 from this function.
3792  *
3793  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3794  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3795  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3796  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3797  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3798  *
3799  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3800  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3801  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3802  *	in suspend().
3803  *
3804  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3805  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3806  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3807  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3808  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3809  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3810  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3811  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3812  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3813  *
3814  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3815  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3816  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3817  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3818  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3819  *
3820  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3821  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3822  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3823  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3824  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3825  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3826  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3827  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3828  *
3829  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3830  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3831  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3832  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3833  *
3834  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3835  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3836  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3837  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3838  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3839  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3840  *	can sleep.
3841  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3842  *	are not implemented.
3843  *
3844  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3845  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3846  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3847  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3848  *	The callback can sleep.
3849  *
3850  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3851  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3852  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3853  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3854  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3855  *	non-MLO connections.
3856  *	The callback can sleep.
3857  *
3858  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3859  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3860  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3861  *
3862  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3863  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3864  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3865  *
3866  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3867  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3868  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3869  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3870  *	which flags are changed.
3871  *	This callback can sleep.
3872  *
3873  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3874  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3875  *
3876  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3877  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3878  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3879  *	is enabled.
3880  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3881  *	The callback can sleep.
3882  *
3883  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3884  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3885  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3886  *	The callback must be atomic.
3887  *
3888  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3889  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3890  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3891  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3892  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3893  *
3894  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3895  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3896  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3897  *
3898  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3899  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3900  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3901  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3902  *	that power save is disabled.
3903  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3904  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3905  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3906  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3907  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3908  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3909  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3910  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3911  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3912  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3913  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3914  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3915  *	The callback can sleep.
3916  *
3917  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3918  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3919  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3920  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3921  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3922  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3923  *	The callback can sleep.
3924  *
3925  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3926  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3927  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3928  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3929  *
3930  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3931  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3932  *
3933  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3934  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3935  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3936  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3937  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3938  *
3939  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3940  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3941  *	this notification.
3942  *	The callback can sleep.
3943  *
3944  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3945  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3946  *	The callback can sleep.
3947  *
3948  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3949  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3950  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3951  *	The callback must be atomic.
3952  *
3953  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3954  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3955  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3956  *	should be set as well.
3957  *	The callback can sleep.
3958  *
3959  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3960  *	The callback can sleep.
3961  *
3962  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3963  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3964  *
3965  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3966  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3967  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3968  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3969  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3970  *	This callback can sleep.
3971  *
3972  * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
3973  *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
3974  *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3975  *
3976  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3977  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3978  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3979  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3980  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3981  *
3982  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3983  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3984  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3985  *	callback can sleep.
3986  *
3987  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3988  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3989  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3990  *	callback can sleep.
3991  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3992  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3993  *
3994  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3995  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3996  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3997  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3998  *
3999  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4000  *	power for the station.
4001  *	This callback can sleep.
4002  *
4003  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4004  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4005  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4006  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4007  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4008  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4009  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4010  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4011  *	The callback can sleep.
4012  *
4013  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4014  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4015  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4016  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4017  *	in @sta_state.
4018  *	The callback can sleep.
4019  *
4020  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
4021  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4022  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4023  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4024  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4025  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4026  *	Must be atomic.
4027  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4028  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4029  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4030  *
4031  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4032  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4033  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4034  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4035  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4036  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4037  *	The callback can sleep.
4038  *
4039  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4040  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4041  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
4042  *	The callback can sleep.
4043  *
4044  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4045  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4046  *	required function.
4047  *	The callback can sleep.
4048  *
4049  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4050  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4051  *	required function.
4052  *	The callback can sleep.
4053  *
4054  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4055  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4056  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4057  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4058  *	The callback can sleep.
4059  *
4060  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4061  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4062  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4063  *	TSF synchronization.
4064  *	The callback can sleep.
4065  *
4066  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4067  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4068  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4069  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4070  *	The callback can sleep.
4071  *
4072  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4073  *
4074  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4075  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4076  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4077  *	The callback can sleep.
4078  *
4079  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4080  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4081  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4082  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4083  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4084  *
4085  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4086  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4087  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4088  *
4089  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4090  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4091  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4092  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4093  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4094  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4095  *	The callback can sleep.
4096  *
4097  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4098  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4099  *	The callback can sleep.
4100  *
4101  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4102  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4103  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4104  *	completion of the channel switch.
4105  *
4106  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4107  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4108  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4109  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4110  *
4111  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4112  *
4113  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4114  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4115  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4116  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4117  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4118  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4119  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4120  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4121  *	must be accepted in this case.
4122  *	This callback may sleep.
4123  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4124  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4125  *
4126  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4127  *
4128  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4129  *
4130  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4131  *	queues before entering power save.
4132  *
4133  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4134  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4135  *	The callback can sleep.
4136  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4137  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4138  *	The callback must be atomic.
4139  *
4140  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4141  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4142  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4143  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4144  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4145  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4146  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4147  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4148  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4149  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4150  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4151  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4152  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4153  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4154  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4155  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4156  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4157  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4158  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4159  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4160  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4161  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4162  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4163  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4164  *	This callback must be atomic.
4165  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4166  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4167  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4168  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4169  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4170  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4171  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4172  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4173  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4174  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4175  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4176  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4177  *	This callback must be atomic.
4178  *
4179  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4180  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4181  *	expected to return a static value.
4182  *
4183  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4184  *
4185  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4186  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4187  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4188  *	expected to return a static value.
4189  *
4190  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4191  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4192  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4193  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4194  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4195  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4196  *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4197  *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4198  *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4199  *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4200  *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4201  *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4202  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4203  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4204  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4205  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4206  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4207  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4208  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4209  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4210  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4211  *
4212  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4213  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4214  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4215  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4216  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4217  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4218  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4219  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4220  *
4221  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4222  *	This callback may sleep.
4223  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4224  *	This callback may sleep.
4225  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4226  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4227  *	channel context with different settings
4228  *	This callback may sleep.
4229  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4230  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4231  *	This callback may sleep.
4232  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4233  *	unbound from vif.
4234  *	This callback may sleep.
4235  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4236  *	another, as specified in the list of
4237  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4238  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4239  *	This callback may sleep.
4240  *
4241  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4242  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4243  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4244  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4245  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4246  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4247  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4248  *
4249  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4250  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4251  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4252  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4253  *	This callback may sleep.
4254  *
4255  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4256  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4257  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4258  *
4259  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4260  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4261  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4262  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4263  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4264  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4265  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4266  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4267  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4268  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4269  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4270  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4271  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4272  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4273  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4274  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4275  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4276  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4277  *	when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4278  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4279  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4280  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4281  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4282  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4283  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4284  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4285  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4286  *
4287  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4288  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4289  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4290  *
4291  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4292  *	and hardware limits.
4293  *
4294  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4295  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4296  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4297  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4298  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4299  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4300  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4301  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4302  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4303  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4304  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4305  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4306  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4307  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4308  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4309  *	the function call.
4310  *
4311  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4312  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4313  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4314  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4315  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4316  *
4317  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4318  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4319  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4320  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4321  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4322  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4323  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4324  *	changed parameters.
4325  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4326  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4327  *	this call.
4328  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4329  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4330  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4331  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4332  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4333  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4334  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4335  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4336  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4337  *
4338  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4339  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4340  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4341  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4342  *	This callback may sleep.
4343  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4344  *	This callback may sleep.
4345  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4346  *	4-address mode
4347  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4348  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4349  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4350  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4351  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4352  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4353  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4354  *	twt structure.
4355  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4356  *	from the peer.
4357  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4358  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4359  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4360  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4361  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4362  *	radar channel.
4363  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4364  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4365  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4366  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4367  * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4368  *	supported by the driver.
4369  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4370  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4371  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4372  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4373  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4374  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4375  *	This callback can sleep.
4376  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4377  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4378  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4379  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4380  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4381  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4382  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4383  *	that.
4384  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4385  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4386  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4387  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4388  * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4389  *	if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4390  *	If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4391  *	modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4392  */
4393 struct ieee80211_ops {
4394 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4395 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4396 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4397 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4398 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4399 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4400 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4401 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4402 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4403 #endif
4404 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4405 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4406 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4407 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4408 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4409 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4410 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4411 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4412 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4413 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4414 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4415 				 u64 changed);
4416 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4417 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4418 				u64 changed);
4419 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4420 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4421 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4422 				  u64 changed);
4423 
4424 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4425 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4426 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4427 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4428 
4429 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4430 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4431 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4432 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4433 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4434 				 u64 multicast);
4435 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4436 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4437 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4438 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4439 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4440 		       bool set);
4441 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4442 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4443 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4444 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4445 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4446 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4447 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4448 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4449 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4450 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4451 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4452 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4453 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4454 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4455 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4456 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4457 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4458 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4459 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4460 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4461 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4462 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4463 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4464 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4465 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4466 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4467 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4468 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4469 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4470 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4471 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4472 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4473 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4474 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4475 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4476 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4477 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4478 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4479 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4480 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4481 	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4482 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4483 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4484 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4485 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4486 				 struct dentry *dir);
4487 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4488 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4489 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4490 				struct dentry *dir);
4491 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4492 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4493 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4494 				     struct dentry *dir);
4495 #endif
4496 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4497 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4498 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4499 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4500 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4501 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4502 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4503 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4504 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4505 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4506 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4507 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4508 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4509 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4510 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4511 			      u32 changed);
4512 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4513 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4514 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4515 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4516 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4517 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4518 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4519 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4520 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4521 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4522 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4523 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4524 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4525 			u64 tsf);
4526 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4527 			   s64 offset);
4528 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4529 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4530 
4531 	/**
4532 	 * @ampdu_action:
4533 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4534 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4535 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4536 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4537 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4538 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4539 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4540 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4541 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4542 	 *
4543 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4544 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4545 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4546 	 *
4547 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4548 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4549 	 *
4550 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4551 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4552 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4553 	 *
4554 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4555 	 *
4556 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4557 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4558 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4559 	 *
4560 	 * The callback can sleep.
4561 	 */
4562 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4563 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4564 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4565 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4566 		struct survey_info *survey);
4567 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4568 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4569 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4570 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571 			    void *data, int len);
4572 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4573 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4574 			     void *data, int len);
4575 #endif
4576 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4577 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4578 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4579 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4580 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4581 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4582 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4583 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4584 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4585 
4586 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4587 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4588 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4589 				 int duration,
4590 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4591 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4593 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4594 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4596 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4597 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4598 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4599 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4600 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4601 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4602 
4603 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4604 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4605 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4606 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4607 				      bool more_data);
4608 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4609 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4610 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4611 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4612 					bool more_data);
4613 
4614 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4615 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4616 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4617 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4618 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4619 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4620 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4621 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4622 
4623 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4624 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4625 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4626 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4627 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4628 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4629 
4630 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4631 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4632 					     unsigned int link_id);
4633 
4634 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4635 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4636 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4637 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4638 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4639 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4640 			       u32 changed);
4641 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4642 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4643 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4644 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4645 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4646 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4647 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4648 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4649 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4650 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4651 				  int n_vifs,
4652 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4653 
4654 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4655 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4656 
4657 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4658 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4659 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4660 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4661 #endif
4662 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4663 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4664 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4665 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4666 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4667 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4668 
4669 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4670 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4671 				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4672 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4673 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4674 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4675 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4676 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4677 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4678 
4679 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4680 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4681 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4682 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4683 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4684 			   int *dbm);
4685 
4686 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4687 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4688 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4689 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4690 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4691 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4692 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4693 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4694 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4695 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4696 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4697 
4698 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4699 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4700 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4701 
4702 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4703 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4704 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4705 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4706 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4707 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4708 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4709 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4710 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4711 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4712 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4713 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4714 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4715 			    u8 instance_id);
4716 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4717 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4718 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4719 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4720 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4721 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4722 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4723 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4724 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4725 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4726 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4727 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4728 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4729 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4730 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4731 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4732 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4733 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4734 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4735 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4736 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4737 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4738 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4739 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4740 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4741 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4742 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4743 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4744 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4745 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4746 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4747 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4748 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4749 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4750 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4751 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4752 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4753 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4754 	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4755 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4756 				   u16 active_links);
4757 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4758 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4759 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4760 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4761 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4762 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4763 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4764 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4765 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4766 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4767 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4768 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4769 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4770 			    struct net_device *dev,
4771 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4772 			    void *type_data);
4773 	enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4774 	(*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4775 			struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4776 };
4777 
4778 /**
4779  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4780  *
4781  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4782  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4783  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4784  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4785  * @priv_data_len.
4786  *
4787  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4788  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4789  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4790  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4791  *
4792  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4793  */
4794 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4795 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4796 					   const char *requested_name);
4797 
4798 /**
4799  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4800  *
4801  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4802  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4803  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4804  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4805  * @priv_data_len.
4806  *
4807  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4808  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4809  *
4810  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4811  */
4812 static inline
4813 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4814 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4815 {
4816 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4817 }
4818 
4819 /**
4820  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4821  *
4822  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4823  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4824  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4825  *
4826  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4827  *
4828  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4829  */
4830 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4831 
4832 /**
4833  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4834  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4835  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4836  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4837  */
4838 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4839 	int throughput;
4840 	int blink_time;
4841 };
4842 
4843 /**
4844  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4845  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4846  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4847  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4848  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4849  */
4850 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4851 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4852 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4853 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4854 };
4855 
4856 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4857 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4858 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4859 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4860 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4861 const char *
4862 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4863 				   unsigned int flags,
4864 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4865 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4866 #endif
4867 /**
4868  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4869  *
4870  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4871  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4872  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4873  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4874  *
4875  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4876  *
4877  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4878  */
4879 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4880 {
4881 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4882 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4883 #else
4884 	return NULL;
4885 #endif
4886 }
4887 
4888 /**
4889  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4890  *
4891  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4892  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4893  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4894  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4895  *
4896  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4897  *
4898  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4899  */
4900 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4901 {
4902 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4903 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4904 #else
4905 	return NULL;
4906 #endif
4907 }
4908 
4909 /**
4910  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4911  *
4912  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4913  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4914  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4915  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4916  *
4917  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4918  *
4919  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4920  */
4921 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4922 {
4923 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4924 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4925 #else
4926 	return NULL;
4927 #endif
4928 }
4929 
4930 /**
4931  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4932  *
4933  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4934  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4935  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4936  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4937  *
4938  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4939  *
4940  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4941  */
4942 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4943 {
4944 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4945 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4946 #else
4947 	return NULL;
4948 #endif
4949 }
4950 
4951 /**
4952  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4953  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4954  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4955  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4956  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4957  *
4958  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4959  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4960  *
4961  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4962  */
4963 static inline const char *
4964 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4965 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4966 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4967 {
4968 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4969 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4970 						  blink_table_len);
4971 #else
4972 	return NULL;
4973 #endif
4974 }
4975 
4976 /**
4977  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4978  *
4979  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4980  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4981  *
4982  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4983  */
4984 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4985 
4986 /**
4987  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4988  *
4989  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4990  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4991  * before calling this function.
4992  *
4993  * @hw: the hardware to free
4994  */
4995 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4996 
4997 /**
4998  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4999  *
5000  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5001  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5002  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5003  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5004  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5005  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5006  *
5007  * @hw: the hardware to restart
5008  */
5009 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5010 
5011 /**
5012  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5013  *
5014  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5015  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5016  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5017  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5018  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5019  *
5020  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5021  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5022  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5023  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5024  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5025  *
5026  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5027  *
5028  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5029  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5030  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5031  * @list: the destination list
5032  */
5033 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5034 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5035 
5036 /**
5037  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5038  *
5039  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5040  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5041  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5042  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5043  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5044  *
5045  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5046  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5047  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5048  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5049  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5050  *
5051  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5052  *
5053  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5054  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5055  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5056  * @napi: the NAPI context
5057  */
5058 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5059 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5060 
5061 /**
5062  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5063  *
5064  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5065  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5066  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5067  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5068  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5069  *
5070  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5071  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5072  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5073  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5074  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5075  *
5076  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5077  *
5078  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5079  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5080  */
5081 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5082 {
5083 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5084 }
5085 
5086 /**
5087  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5088  *
5089  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5090  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5091  *
5092  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5093  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5094  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5095  *
5096  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5097  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5098  */
5099 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5100 
5101 /**
5102  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5103  *
5104  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5105  * (internally disables bottom halves).
5106  *
5107  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5108  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5109  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5110  *
5111  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5112  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5113  */
5114 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5115 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5116 {
5117 	local_bh_disable();
5118 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5119 	local_bh_enable();
5120 }
5121 
5122 /**
5123  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5124  *
5125  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5126  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5127  * entering/leaving PS mode.
5128  *
5129  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5130  *
5131  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5132  * each other.
5133  *
5134  * @sta: currently connected sta
5135  * @start: start or stop PS
5136  *
5137  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5138  */
5139 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5140 
5141 /**
5142  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5143  *                                  (in process context)
5144  *
5145  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5146  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5147  * applies.
5148  *
5149  * @sta: currently connected sta
5150  * @start: start or stop PS
5151  *
5152  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5153  */
5154 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5155 						  bool start)
5156 {
5157 	int ret;
5158 
5159 	local_bh_disable();
5160 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5161 	local_bh_enable();
5162 
5163 	return ret;
5164 }
5165 
5166 /**
5167  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5168  * @sta: currently connected station
5169  *
5170  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5171  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5172  * connected station was received.
5173  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5174  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5175  * be serialized.
5176  */
5177 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5178 
5179 /**
5180  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5181  * @sta: currently connected station
5182  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5183  *
5184  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5185  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5186  * from a connected station was received.
5187  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5188  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5189  * serialized.
5190  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5191  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5192  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5193  * checks.
5194  */
5195 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5196 
5197 /*
5198  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5199  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5200  */
5201 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5202 
5203 /**
5204  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5205  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5206  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5207  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5208  *
5209  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5210  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5211  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5212  *
5213  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5214  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5215  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5216  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5217  *
5218  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5219  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5220  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5221  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5222  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5223  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5224  *
5225  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5226  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5227  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5228  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5229  * use this API.
5230  */
5231 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5232 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5233 
5234 /**
5235  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5236  *
5237  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5238  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5239  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5240  *
5241  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5242  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5243  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5244  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5245  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5246  */
5247 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5248 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5249 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5250 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5251 			    int max_rates);
5252 
5253 /**
5254  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5255  *
5256  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5257  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5258  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5259  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5260  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5261  * slow stations to starve).
5262  *
5263  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5264  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5265  */
5266 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5267 					   u32 thr);
5268 
5269 /**
5270  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5271  *
5272  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5273  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5274  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5275  *
5276  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5277  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5278  * @info: tx status information
5279  */
5280 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5281 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5282 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5283 
5284 /**
5285  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5286  *
5287  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5288  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5289  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5290  *
5291  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5292  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5293  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5294  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5295  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5296  *
5297  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5298  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5299  */
5300 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5301 			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5302 
5303 /**
5304  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5305  *
5306  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5307  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5308  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5309  *
5310  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5311  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5312  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5313  *
5314  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5315  * @status: tx status information
5316  */
5317 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5318 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5319 
5320 /**
5321  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5322  *
5323  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5324  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5325  * specific skbs.
5326  *
5327  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5328  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5329  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5330  *
5331  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5332  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5333  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5334  * @info: tx status information
5335  */
5336 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5337 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5338 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5339 {
5340 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5341 		.sta = sta,
5342 		.info = info,
5343 	};
5344 
5345 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5346 }
5347 
5348 /**
5349  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5350  *
5351  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5352  *
5353  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5354  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5355  * for a single hardware.
5356  *
5357  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5358  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5359  */
5360 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5361 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5362 {
5363 	local_bh_disable();
5364 	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5365 	local_bh_enable();
5366 }
5367 
5368 /**
5369  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5370  *
5371  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5372  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5373  *
5374  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5375  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5376  *
5377  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5378  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5379  */
5380 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5381 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5382 
5383 /**
5384  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5385  *
5386  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5387  * connected STA.
5388  *
5389  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5390  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5391  */
5392 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5393 
5394 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5395 
5396 /**
5397  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5398  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5399  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5400  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5401  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5402  *	should be ignored.
5403  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5404  */
5405 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5406 	u16 tim_offset;
5407 	u16 tim_length;
5408 
5409 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5410 	u16 mbssid_off;
5411 };
5412 
5413 /**
5414  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5415  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5416  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5417  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5418  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5419  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5420  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5421  *
5422  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5423  * obtain the beacon template.
5424  *
5425  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5426  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5427  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5428  * applicable, the CSA count.
5429  *
5430  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5431  *
5432  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5433  */
5434 struct sk_buff *
5435 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5436 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5437 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5438 			      unsigned int link_id);
5439 
5440 /**
5441  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5442  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5443  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5444  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5445  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5446  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5447  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5448  *
5449  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5450  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5451  * requested index.
5452  *
5453  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5454  */
5455 struct sk_buff *
5456 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5457 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5458 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5459 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5460 
5461 /**
5462  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5463  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5464  *
5465  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5466  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5467  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5468  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5469  */
5470 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5471 	u8 cnt;
5472 	struct {
5473 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5474 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5475 	} bcn[];
5476 };
5477 
5478 /**
5479  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5480  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5481  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5482  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5483  *
5484  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5485  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5486  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5487  * one multiple BSSID element.
5488  *
5489  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5490  *
5491  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5492  *	%NULL on error.
5493  */
5494 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5495 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5496 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5497 				       unsigned int link_id);
5498 
5499 /**
5500  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5501  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5502  *
5503  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5504  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5505  */
5506 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5507 
5508 /**
5509  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5510  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5511  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5512  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5513  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5514  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5515  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5516  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5517  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5518  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5519  *
5520  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5521  * obtain the beacon frame.
5522  *
5523  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5524  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5525  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5526  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5527  *
5528  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5529  *
5530  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5531  */
5532 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5533 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5534 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5535 					 unsigned int link_id);
5536 
5537 /**
5538  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5539  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5540  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5541  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5542  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5543  *
5544  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5545  *
5546  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5547  */
5548 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5549 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5550 						   unsigned int link_id)
5551 {
5552 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5553 }
5554 
5555 /**
5556  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5557  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5558  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5559  *
5560  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5561  * This function is called implicitly when
5562  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5563  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5564  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5565  *
5566  * Return: new countdown value
5567  */
5568 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5569 				  unsigned int link_id);
5570 
5571 /**
5572  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5573  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5574  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5575  *
5576  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5577  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5578  *
5579  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5580  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5581  */
5582 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5583 
5584 /**
5585  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5586  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5587  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5588  *
5589  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5590  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5591  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5592  */
5593 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5594 
5595 /**
5596  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5597  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5598  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5599  *
5600  * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5601  */
5602 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5603 					 unsigned int link_id);
5604 
5605 /**
5606  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5607  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5608  *
5609  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5610  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5611  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5612  */
5613 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5614 
5615 /**
5616  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5617  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5618  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5619  *
5620  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5621  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5622  *
5623  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5624  *
5625  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5626  */
5627 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5628 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5629 
5630 /**
5631  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5632  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5633  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5634  *
5635  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5636  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5637  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5638  *
5639  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5640  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5641  *
5642  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5643  */
5644 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5645 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5646 
5647 /**
5648  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5649  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5650  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5651  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5652  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5653  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5654  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5655  *	if at all possible
5656  *
5657  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5658  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5659  * BSSID and address is used.
5660  *
5661  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5662  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5663  *
5664  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5665  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5666  *
5667  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5668  */
5669 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5670 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5671 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5672 
5673 /**
5674  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5675  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5676  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5677  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5678  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5679  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5680  *
5681  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5682  * hardware.
5683  *
5684  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5685  */
5686 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5687 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5688 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5689 				       size_t tailroom);
5690 
5691 /**
5692  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5693  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5694  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5695  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5696  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5697  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5698  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5699  *
5700  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5701  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5702  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5703  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5704  */
5705 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5706 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5707 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5708 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5709 
5710 /**
5711  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5712  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5713  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5714  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5715  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5716  *
5717  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5718  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5719  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5720  *
5721  * Return: The duration.
5722  */
5723 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5724 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5725 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5726 
5727 /**
5728  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5729  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5730  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5731  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5732  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5733  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5734  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5735  *
5736  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5737  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5738  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5739  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5740  */
5741 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5742 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5743 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5744 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5745 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5746 
5747 /**
5748  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5749  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5750  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5751  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5752  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5753  *
5754  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5755  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5756  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5757  *
5758  * Return: The duration.
5759  */
5760 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5761 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5762 				    size_t frame_len,
5763 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5764 
5765 /**
5766  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5767  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5768  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5769  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5770  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5771  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5772  *
5773  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5774  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5775  *
5776  * Return: The duration.
5777  */
5778 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5779 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5780 					enum nl80211_band band,
5781 					size_t frame_len,
5782 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5783 
5784 /**
5785  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5786  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5787  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5788  *
5789  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5790  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5791  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5792  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5793  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5794  *
5795  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5796  * frames are available.
5797  *
5798  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5799  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5800  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5801  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5802  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5803  * use common code for all beacons.
5804  */
5805 struct sk_buff *
5806 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5807 
5808 /**
5809  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5810  *
5811  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5812  *
5813  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5814  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5815  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5816  */
5817 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5818 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5819 
5820 /**
5821  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5822  *
5823  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5824  * from the given packet.
5825  *
5826  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5827  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5828  *	with this P1K
5829  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5830  */
5831 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5832 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5833 {
5834 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5835 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5836 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5837 
5838 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5839 }
5840 
5841 /**
5842  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5843  *
5844  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5845  * and transmitter address.
5846  *
5847  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5848  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5849  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5850  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5851  */
5852 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5853 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5854 
5855 /**
5856  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5857  *
5858  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5859  * in the packet.
5860  *
5861  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5862  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5863  *	encrypted with this key
5864  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5865  */
5866 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5867 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5868 
5869 /**
5870  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5871  *
5872  * @pos: start of crypto header
5873  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5874  * @pn: PN to add
5875  *
5876  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5877  * the packet payload)
5878  *
5879  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5880  * point to the crypto header)
5881  */
5882 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5883 
5884 /**
5885  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5886  *
5887  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5888  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5889  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5890  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5891  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5892  *
5893  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5894  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5895  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5896  *
5897  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5898  * can be done concurrently.
5899  */
5900 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5901 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5902 
5903 /**
5904  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5905  *
5906  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5907  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5908  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5909  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5910  * @seq: new sequence data
5911  *
5912  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5913  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5914  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5915  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5916  *
5917  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5918  * can be done concurrently.
5919  */
5920 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5921 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5922 
5923 /**
5924  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5925  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5926  *
5927  * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
5928  *
5929  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5930  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5931  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5932  */
5933 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5934 
5935 /**
5936  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5937  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5938  * @keyconf: new key data
5939  * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
5940  *
5941  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5942  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5943  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5944  *
5945  * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5946  * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5947  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5948  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5949  *
5950  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5951  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5952  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5953  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5954  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5955  * of the reconfiguration.
5956  *
5957  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5958  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5959  *
5960  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5961  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5962  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5963  * the key that's being replaced.
5964  */
5965 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5966 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5967 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5968 			int link_id);
5969 
5970 /**
5971  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5972  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5973  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5974  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5975  * @gfp: allocation flags
5976  */
5977 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5978 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5979 
5980 /**
5981  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5982  *
5983  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5984  * at the same time.
5985  *
5986  * @keyconf: the key in question
5987  */
5988 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5989 
5990 /**
5991  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5992  *
5993  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5994  * at the same time.
5995  *
5996  * @keyconf: the key in question
5997  */
5998 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5999 
6000 /**
6001  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6002  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6003  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6004  *
6005  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6006  */
6007 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6008 
6009 /**
6010  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6011  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6012  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6013  *
6014  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6015  */
6016 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6017 
6018 /**
6019  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6020  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6021  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6022  *
6023  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6024  *
6025  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6026  */
6027 
6028 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6029 
6030 /**
6031  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6032  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6033  *
6034  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6035  */
6036 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6037 
6038 /**
6039  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6040  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6041  *
6042  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6043  */
6044 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6045 
6046 /**
6047  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6048  *
6049  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6050  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6051  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6052  * any context, including hardirq context.
6053  *
6054  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6055  * @info: information about the completed scan
6056  */
6057 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6058 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6059 
6060 /**
6061  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6062  *
6063  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6064  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6065  *
6066  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6067  */
6068 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6069 
6070 /**
6071  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6072  *
6073  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6074  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6075  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6076  * while associating, for instance.
6077  *
6078  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6079  */
6080 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6081 
6082 /**
6083  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6084  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6085  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6086  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6087  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6088  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6089  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6090  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6091  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6092  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6093  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6094  *	for instance.
6095  */
6096 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6097 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
6098 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
6099 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
6100 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
6101 };
6102 
6103 /**
6104  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6105  *
6106  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6107  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6108  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6109  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6110  *
6111  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6112  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6113  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6114  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6115  */
6116 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6117 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6118 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6119 				  void *data);
6120 
6121 /**
6122  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6123  *
6124  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6125  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6126  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6127  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6128  * be used.
6129  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6130  *
6131  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6132  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6133  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6134  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6135  */
6136 static inline void
6137 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6138 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6139 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6140 				    void *data)
6141 {
6142 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6143 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6144 				     iterator, data);
6145 }
6146 
6147 /**
6148  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6149  *
6150  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6151  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6152  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6153  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6154  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6155  *
6156  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6157  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6158  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6159  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6160  */
6161 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6162 						u32 iter_flags,
6163 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6164 						    u8 *mac,
6165 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6166 						void *data);
6167 
6168 /**
6169  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6170  *
6171  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6172  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6173  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6174  *
6175  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6176  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6177  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6178  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6179  */
6180 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6181 					     u32 iter_flags,
6182 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6183 						u8 *mac,
6184 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6185 					     void *data);
6186 
6187 /**
6188  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6189  *
6190  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6191  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6192  * function for them.
6193  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6194  *
6195  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6196  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6197  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6198  */
6199 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6200 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6201 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6202 				       void *data);
6203 /**
6204  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6205  *
6206  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6207  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6208  *
6209  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6210  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6211  */
6212 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6213 
6214 /**
6215  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6216  *
6217  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6218  * workqueue.
6219  *
6220  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6221  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6222  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6223  */
6224 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6225 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6226 				  unsigned long delay);
6227 
6228 /**
6229  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6230  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6231  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6232  *
6233  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6234  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6235  * mac80211.
6236  *
6237  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6238  */
6239 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6240 					    u16 tid);
6241 
6242 /**
6243  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6244  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6245  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6246  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6247  *
6248  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6249  *
6250  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6251  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6252  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6253  */
6254 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6255 				  u16 timeout);
6256 
6257 /**
6258  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6259  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6260  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6261  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6262  *
6263  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6264  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6265  * from any context.
6266  */
6267 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6268 				      u16 tid);
6269 
6270 /**
6271  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6272  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6273  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6274  *
6275  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6276  *
6277  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6278  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6279  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6280  */
6281 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6282 
6283 /**
6284  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6285  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6286  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6287  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6288  *
6289  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6290  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6291  * can be called from any context.
6292  */
6293 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6294 				     u16 tid);
6295 
6296 /**
6297  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6298  *
6299  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6300  * @addr: station's address
6301  *
6302  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6303  *
6304  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6305  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6306  */
6307 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6308 					 const u8 *addr);
6309 
6310 /**
6311  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6312  *
6313  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6314  * @addr: remote station's address
6315  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6316  *
6317  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6318  *
6319  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6320  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6321  *
6322  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6323  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6324  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6325  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6326  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6327  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6328  *      is not reliable.
6329  *
6330  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6331  */
6332 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6333 					       const u8 *addr,
6334 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6335 
6336 /**
6337  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6338  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6339  * @addr: remote station's link address
6340  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6341  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6342  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6343  *
6344  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6345  */
6346 struct ieee80211_sta *
6347 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6348 				 const u8 *addr,
6349 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6350 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6351 
6352 /**
6353  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6354  * @hw: the hardware
6355  * @pubsta: the station
6356  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6357  *
6358  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6359  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6360  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6361  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6362  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6363  *
6364  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6365  * manner.
6366  *
6367  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6368  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6369  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6370  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6371  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6372  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6373  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6374  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6375  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6376  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6377  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6378  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6379  * woke up while blocked or not.
6380  */
6381 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6382 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6383 
6384 /**
6385  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6386  * @pubsta: the station
6387  *
6388  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6389  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6390  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6391  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6392  *
6393  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6394  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6395  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6396  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6397  *
6398  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6399  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6400  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6401  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6402  */
6403 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6404 
6405 /**
6406  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6407  * @pubsta: the station
6408  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6409  *
6410  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6411  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6412  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6413  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6414  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6415  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6416  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6417  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6418  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6419  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6420  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6421  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6422  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6423  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6424  */
6425 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6426 
6427 /**
6428  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6429  * @pubsta: the station
6430  *
6431  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6432  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6433  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6434  *
6435  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6436  * there is no need to call this function.
6437  */
6438 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6439 
6440 /**
6441  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6442  *
6443  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6444  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6445  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6446  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6447  *
6448  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6449  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6450  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6451  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6452  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6453  * attempts.
6454  *
6455  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6456  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6457  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6458  * them to 0.
6459  *
6460  * @pubsta: the station
6461  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6462  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6463  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6464  */
6465 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6466 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6467 
6468 /**
6469  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6470  *
6471  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6472  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6473  *
6474  * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6475  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6476  */
6477 bool
6478 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6479 
6480 /**
6481  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6482  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6483  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6484  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6485  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6486  *
6487  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6488  *
6489  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6490  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6491  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6492  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6493  *
6494  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6495  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6496  * set_key callback.
6497  */
6498 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6499 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6500 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6501 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6502 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6503 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6504 				      void *data),
6505 			 void *iter_data);
6506 
6507 /**
6508  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6509  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6510  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6511  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6512  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6513  *
6514  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6515  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6516  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6517  * in removal process will be skipped.
6518  *
6519  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6520  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6521  */
6522 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6523 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6524 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6525 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6526 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6527 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6528 					  void *data),
6529 			     void *iter_data);
6530 
6531 /**
6532  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6533  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6534  * @iter: iterator function
6535  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6536  *
6537  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6538  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6539  * places while calling into the driver.
6540  *
6541  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6542  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6543  * removed.
6544  *
6545  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6546  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6547  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6548  * or not.
6549  */
6550 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6551 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6552 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6553 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6554 		     void *data),
6555 	void *iter_data);
6556 
6557 /**
6558  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6559  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6560  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6561  *
6562  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6563  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6564  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6565  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6566  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6567  * %NULL.
6568  *
6569  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6570  */
6571 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6572 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6573 
6574 /**
6575  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6576  *
6577  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6578  *
6579  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6580  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6581  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6582  */
6583 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6584 
6585 /**
6586  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6587  *
6588  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6589  *
6590  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6591  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6592  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6593  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6594  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6595  *
6596  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6597  * without connection recovery attempts.
6598  */
6599 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6600 
6601 /**
6602  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6603  *
6604  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6605  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6606  *
6607  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6608  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6609  */
6610 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6611 
6612 /**
6613  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6614  *
6615  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6616  *
6617  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6618  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6619  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6620  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6621  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6622  *
6623  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6624  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6625  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6626  * disconnect normally later.
6627  *
6628  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6629  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6630  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6631  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6632  */
6633 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6634 
6635 /**
6636  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6637  * hardware restart
6638  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6639  *
6640  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6641  * hardware restart.
6642  */
6643 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6644 
6645 /**
6646  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6647  *	rssi threshold triggered
6648  *
6649  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6650  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6651  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6652  * @gfp: context flags
6653  *
6654  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6655  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6656  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6657  */
6658 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6659 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6660 			       s32 rssi_level,
6661 			       gfp_t gfp);
6662 
6663 /**
6664  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6665  *
6666  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6667  * @gfp: context flags
6668  */
6669 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6670 
6671 /**
6672  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6673  *
6674  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6675  */
6676 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6677 
6678 /**
6679  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6680  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6681  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6682  * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6683  *	false.
6684  *
6685  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6686  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6687  */
6688 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6689 			     unsigned int link_id);
6690 
6691 /**
6692  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6693  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6694  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6695  *
6696  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6697  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6698  * a deauth frame in this case.
6699  */
6700 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6701 					 bool block_tx);
6702 
6703 /**
6704  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6705  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6706  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6707  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6708  *
6709  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6710  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6711  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6712  */
6713 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6714 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6715 
6716 /**
6717  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6718  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6719  */
6720 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6721 
6722 /**
6723  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6724  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6725  */
6726 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6727 
6728 /**
6729  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6730  *
6731  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6732  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6733  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6734  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6735  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6736  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6737  *
6738  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6739  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6740  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6741  */
6742 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6743 				  const u8 *addr);
6744 
6745 /**
6746  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6747  * @pubsta: station struct
6748  * @tid: the session's TID
6749  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6750  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6751  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6752  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6753  *
6754  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6755  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6756  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6757  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6758  * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6759  */
6760 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6761 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6762 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6763 
6764 /**
6765  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6766  *
6767  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6768  * buffer.
6769  *
6770  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6771  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6772  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6773  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6774  */
6775 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6776 
6777 /**
6778  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6779  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6780  * @addr: station mac address
6781  * @tid: the rx tid
6782  */
6783 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6784 				 unsigned int tid);
6785 
6786 /**
6787  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6788  *
6789  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6790  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6791  * reordering.
6792  *
6793  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6794  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6795  *
6796  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6797  * @addr: station mac address
6798  * @tid: the rx tid
6799  */
6800 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6801 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6802 {
6803 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6804 		return;
6805 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6806 }
6807 
6808 /**
6809  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6810  *
6811  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6812  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6813  * reordering.
6814  *
6815  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6816  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6817  *
6818  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6819  * @addr: station mac address
6820  * @tid: the rx tid
6821  */
6822 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6823 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6824 {
6825 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6826 		return;
6827 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6828 }
6829 
6830 /**
6831  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6832  *
6833  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6834  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6835  *
6836  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6837  *
6838  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6839  * @addr: station mac address
6840  * @tid: the rx tid
6841  */
6842 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6843 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6844 
6845 /* Rate control API */
6846 
6847 /**
6848  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6849  *
6850  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6851  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6852  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6853  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6854  *	to be filled in
6855  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6856  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6857  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6858  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6859  *	RTS threshold
6860  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6861  *	if the selected rate supports it
6862  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6863  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6864  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6865  */
6866 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6867 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6868 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6869 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6870 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6871 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6872 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6873 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6874 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6875 	bool bss;
6876 };
6877 
6878 /**
6879  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6880  */
6881 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6882 	/**
6883 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6884 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6885 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6886 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6887 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6888 	 */
6889 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6890 	/**
6891 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6892 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6893 	 */
6894 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6895 };
6896 
6897 struct rate_control_ops {
6898 	unsigned long capa;
6899 	const char *name;
6900 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6901 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6902 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6903 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6904 
6905 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6906 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6907 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6908 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6909 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6910 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6911 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6912 			    u32 changed);
6913 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6914 			 void *priv_sta);
6915 
6916 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6917 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6918 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6919 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6920 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6921 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6922 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6923 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6924 
6925 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6926 				struct dentry *dir);
6927 
6928 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6929 };
6930 
6931 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6932 				 enum nl80211_band band,
6933 				 int index)
6934 {
6935 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6936 }
6937 
6938 static inline s8
6939 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6940 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6941 {
6942 	int i;
6943 
6944 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6945 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6946 			return i;
6947 
6948 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6949 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6950 
6951 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6952 	return 0;
6953 }
6954 
6955 static inline
6956 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6957 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6958 {
6959 	unsigned int i;
6960 
6961 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6962 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6963 			return true;
6964 	return false;
6965 }
6966 
6967 /**
6968  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6969  *
6970  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6971  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6972  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6973  * the most recent rate control module decision.
6974  *
6975  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6976  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6977  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6978  */
6979 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6980 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6981 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6982 
6983 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6984 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6985 
6986 static inline bool
6987 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6988 {
6989 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6990 }
6991 
6992 static inline bool
6993 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6994 {
6995 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6996 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6997 }
6998 
6999 static inline bool
7000 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7001 {
7002 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7003 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7004 }
7005 
7006 static inline bool
7007 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7008 {
7009 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7010 }
7011 
7012 static inline bool
7013 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7014 {
7015 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7016 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7017 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7018 }
7019 
7020 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7021 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7022 {
7023 	if (p2p) {
7024 		switch (type) {
7025 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7026 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7027 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7028 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7029 		default:
7030 			break;
7031 		}
7032 	}
7033 	return type;
7034 }
7035 
7036 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7037 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7038 {
7039 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7040 }
7041 
7042 /**
7043  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7044  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7045  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7046  *
7047  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7048  */
7049 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
7050 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7051 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7052 {
7053 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7054 }
7055 
7056 /**
7057  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7058  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7059  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7060  *
7061  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7062  */
7063 static inline __le16
7064 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7065 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7066 {
7067 	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7068 }
7069 
7070 /**
7071  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7072  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7073  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7074  *
7075  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7076  */
7077 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
7078 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7079 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7080 {
7081 	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7082 }
7083 
7084 /**
7085  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7086  *
7087  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7088  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7089  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7090  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7091  *
7092  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7093  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7094  * matching GroupId management frame.
7095  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7096  */
7097 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7098 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7099 
7100 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7101 				   int rssi_min_thold,
7102 				   int rssi_max_thold);
7103 
7104 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7105 
7106 /**
7107  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7108  *
7109  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7110  *
7111  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7112  *
7113  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7114  * applicable.
7115  */
7116 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7117 
7118 /**
7119  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7120  * @vif: virtual interface
7121  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7122  * @gfp: allocation flags
7123  *
7124  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7125  */
7126 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7127 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7128 				    gfp_t gfp);
7129 
7130 /**
7131  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7132  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7133  * @vif: virtual interface
7134  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7135  * @band: the band to transmit on
7136  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7137  *
7138  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7139  */
7140 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7141 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7142 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7143 
7144 /**
7145  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7146  *				 of injected frames.
7147  *
7148  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7149  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7150  * of the skb before calling this function.
7151  *
7152  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7153  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7154  */
7155 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7156 				 struct net_device *dev);
7157 
7158 /**
7159  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7160  *
7161  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7162  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7163  *
7164  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7165  *
7166  * private:
7167  *
7168  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7169  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7170  */
7171 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7172 	u32 next_tsf;
7173 	bool has_next_tsf;
7174 
7175 	u8 absent;
7176 
7177 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7178 	struct {
7179 		u32 start;
7180 		u32 duration;
7181 		u32 interval;
7182 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7183 };
7184 
7185 /**
7186  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7187  *
7188  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7189  * @data: NoA tracking data
7190  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7191  *
7192  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7193  */
7194 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7195 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7196 
7197 /**
7198  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7199  *
7200  * @data: NoA tracking data
7201  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7202  */
7203 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7204 
7205 /**
7206  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7207  * @vif: virtual interface
7208  * @peer: the peer's destination address
7209  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7210  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7211  * @gfp: allocation flags
7212  *
7213  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7214  */
7215 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7216 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7217 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7218 
7219 /**
7220  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7221  *
7222  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7223  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7224  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7225  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7226  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7227  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7228  *
7229  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7230  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7231  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7232  *
7233  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7234  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7235  *
7236  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7237  */
7238 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7239 
7240 /**
7241  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7242  *
7243  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7244  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7245  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7246  *
7247  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7248  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7249  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7250  *
7251  * @sta: the station
7252  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7253  */
7254 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7255 
7256 /**
7257  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7258  *
7259  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7260  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7261  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7262  *
7263  * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7264  *
7265  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7266  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7267  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7268  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7269  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7270  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7271  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7272  *
7273  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7274  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7275  */
7276 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7277 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7278 
7279 /**
7280  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7281  * (in process context)
7282  *
7283  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7284  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7285  *
7286  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7287  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7288  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7289  */
7290 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7291 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7292 {
7293 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7294 
7295 	local_bh_disable();
7296 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7297 	local_bh_enable();
7298 
7299 	return skb;
7300 }
7301 
7302 /**
7303  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7304  *
7305  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7306  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7307  *
7308  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7309  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7310  */
7311 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7312 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7313 
7314 /**
7315  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7316  *
7317  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7318  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7319  *
7320  * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7321  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7322  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7323  */
7324 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7325 
7326 /**
7327  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7328  *
7329  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7330  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7331  *
7332  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7333  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7334  */
7335 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7336 
7337 /* (deprecated) */
7338 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7339 {
7340 }
7341 
7342 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7343 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7344 
7345 /**
7346  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7347  *
7348  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7349  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7350  *
7351  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7352  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7353  *
7354  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7355  * this TXQ internally.
7356  */
7357 static inline void
7358 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7359 {
7360 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7361 }
7362 
7363 /**
7364  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7365  *
7366  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7367  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7368  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7369  *
7370  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7371  * internally.
7372  */
7373 static inline void
7374 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7375 		     bool force)
7376 {
7377 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7378 }
7379 
7380 /**
7381  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7382  *
7383  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7384  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7385  * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7386  * next_txq().
7387  *
7388  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7389  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7390  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7391  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7392  * again.
7393  *
7394  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7395  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7396  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7397  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7398  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7399  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7400  *
7401  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7402  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7403  */
7404 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7405 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7406 
7407 /**
7408  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7409  *
7410  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7411  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7412  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7413  *
7414  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7415  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7416  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7417  */
7418 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7419 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7420 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7421 
7422 /**
7423  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7424  *
7425  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7426  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7427  *
7428  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7429  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7430  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7431  * @gfp: allocation flags
7432  */
7433 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7434 				   u8 inst_id,
7435 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7436 				   gfp_t gfp);
7437 
7438 /**
7439  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7440  *
7441  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7442  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7443  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7444  *
7445  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7446  * @match: match event information
7447  * @gfp: allocation flags
7448  */
7449 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7450 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7451 			      gfp_t gfp);
7452 
7453 /**
7454  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7455  *
7456  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7457  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7458  *
7459  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7460  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7461  *          information.
7462  * @len: frame length in bytes
7463  */
7464 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7465 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7466 			      int len);
7467 
7468 /**
7469  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7470  *
7471  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7472  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7473  *
7474  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7475  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7476  * @len: frame length in bytes
7477  */
7478 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7479 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7480 			      int len);
7481 /**
7482  * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7483  *
7484  * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7485  * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7486  * hardware or firmware.
7487  *
7488  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7489  * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7490  */
7491 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7492 
7493 /**
7494  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7495  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7496  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7497  *
7498  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7499  *
7500  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7501  */
7502 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7503 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7504 
7505 /**
7506  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7507  *	probe response template.
7508  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7509  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7510  *
7511  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7512  *
7513  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7514  */
7515 struct sk_buff *
7516 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7517 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7518 
7519 /**
7520  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7521  * collision.
7522  *
7523  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7524  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7525  *	aware of.
7526  */
7527 void
7528 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7529 				      u64 color_bitmap);
7530 
7531 /**
7532  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7533  *
7534  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7535  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7536  *
7537  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7538  */
7539 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7540 {
7541 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7542 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7543 
7544 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7545 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7546 }
7547 
7548 /**
7549  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7550  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7551  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7552  *
7553  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7554  *	back into the driver.
7555  *
7556  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7557  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7558  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7559  *
7560  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7561  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7562  * a sequence of calls like
7563  *
7564  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7565  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7566  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7567  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7568  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7569  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7570  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7571  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7572  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7573  */
7574 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7575 
7576 /**
7577  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7578  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7579  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7580  *
7581  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7582  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7583  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7584  * completed after it returns.
7585  */
7586 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7587 				      u16 active_links);
7588 
7589 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7590 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7591 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7592 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7593 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7594 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7595 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7596 				      u32 changed);
7597 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7598 					 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7599 					 int n_vifs,
7600 					 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7601 
7602 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7603